1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type,
57 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
58 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
60 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
61 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
62 need to move into elfcode.h. */
64 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
67 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
68 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
69 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
71 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
72 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
73 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
74 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
75 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
76 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
77 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
80 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
83 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
84 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
85 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
90 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
93 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
96 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
99 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
100 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
101 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
103 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
104 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
107 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
110 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
111 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
112 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
115 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
118 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
121 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
122 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
123 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
125 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
126 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
127 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
128 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
129 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
132 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
135 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
136 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
137 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
140 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
143 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
146 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
149 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
150 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
151 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
153 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
154 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
155 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
156 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
157 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
160 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
163 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
164 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
165 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
167 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
169 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
171 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
174 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
177 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
178 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
179 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
181 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
184 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
187 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
188 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
189 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
191 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
194 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
195 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
198 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
200 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
205 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
208 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
211 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
212 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
216 return h & 0xffffffff;
219 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
220 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
223 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
225 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
226 unsigned long h = 5381;
229 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
230 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
231 return h & 0xffffffff;
234 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
235 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
237 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
239 enum elf_target_id object_id)
241 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
242 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
243 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
246 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
247 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
249 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
252 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
253 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
260 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
262 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
263 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
268 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
270 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
271 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
273 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
274 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
278 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
280 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
281 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
283 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
285 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
287 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
288 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
291 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
292 if (shstrtab == NULL)
294 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
295 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
296 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
298 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
299 in case the string table is not terminated. */
300 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
301 || shstrtabsize > bfd_get_file_size (abfd)
302 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
303 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
305 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
307 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
308 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
309 bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
311 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
312 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
313 the string table over and over. */
314 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
317 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
318 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
320 return (char *) shstrtab;
324 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
325 unsigned int shindex,
326 unsigned int strindex)
328 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
333 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
336 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
338 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
340 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
342 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
343 /* xgettext:c-format */
344 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
345 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
350 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
354 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
356 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
358 /* xgettext:c-format */
359 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
360 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
361 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
363 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
367 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
370 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
371 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
372 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
373 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
374 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
375 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
376 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
379 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
380 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
383 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
385 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
387 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
389 const bfd_byte *esym;
390 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
391 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
392 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
393 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
394 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
395 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
400 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
406 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
408 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
410 elf_section_list * entry;
411 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
413 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
414 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
417 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
420 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
422 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
427 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
429 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
430 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
431 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
432 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
433 the index table will not be needed. */
437 /* Read the symbols. */
439 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
441 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
442 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
443 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
444 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
445 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
447 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
448 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
450 if (extsym_buf == NULL
451 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
452 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
458 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
462 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
463 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
464 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
466 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
467 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
468 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
470 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
471 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
472 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
479 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
481 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
482 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
483 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
484 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
488 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
489 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
490 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
491 shndx = extshndx_buf;
493 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
494 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
496 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
497 /* xgettext:c-format */
498 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
499 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
500 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
501 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
508 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
510 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
511 free (alloc_extshndx);
516 /* Look up a symbol name. */
518 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
519 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
520 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
524 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
525 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
527 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
528 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
529 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
531 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
532 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
535 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
538 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
539 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
544 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
545 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
548 typedef union elf_internal_group {
549 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
551 } Elf_Internal_Group;
553 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
554 signature just a string? */
557 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
559 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
560 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
561 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
562 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
564 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
565 that it is a symbol table section. */
566 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
568 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
569 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
570 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
573 /* Go read the symbol. */
574 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
575 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
576 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
579 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
582 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
585 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
587 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
589 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
590 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
593 unsigned int i, shnum;
595 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
596 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
597 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
600 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
601 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
602 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
603 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
604 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
606 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
608 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
610 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
616 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
617 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
618 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
622 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
623 so we can find them quickly. */
626 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
627 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
628 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
629 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
631 memset (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr, 0,
632 num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
635 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
637 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
639 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
642 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
644 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
646 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
649 /* Add to list of sections. */
650 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
653 /* Read the raw contents. */
654 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
655 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
656 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
657 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
658 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
659 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
662 /* xgettext:c-format */
663 (_("%pB: corrupt size field in group section"
664 " header: %#" PRIx64),
665 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
666 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
671 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
673 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
674 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
678 /* xgettext:c-format */
679 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
680 " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
681 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
682 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
684 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
685 partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
686 contents to be used. */
687 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
691 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
692 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
693 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
695 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
696 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
704 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
705 if (src == shdr->contents)
708 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
709 shdr->bfd_section->flags
710 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
715 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
716 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
717 section group should be marked with
718 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
719 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
721 dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
724 || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
727 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
735 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
736 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
738 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
740 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
743 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
744 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
746 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
747 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
753 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
755 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
758 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
760 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
761 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
763 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
764 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
770 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
771 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
773 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
774 /* xgettext:c-format */
775 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
776 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
777 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
778 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
781 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
783 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
784 section is a member. */
786 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
790 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
791 other members to see if any others are linked via
793 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
794 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
796 if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
797 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
798 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
802 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
803 insert current section in circular list. */
804 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
805 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
806 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
812 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
815 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
817 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
818 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
821 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
823 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
824 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
826 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
833 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
835 /* xgettext:c-format */
836 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
844 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
847 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
848 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
851 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
852 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
854 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
855 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
857 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
858 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
859 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
860 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
863 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
864 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
865 bed->link_order_error_handler
866 /* xgettext:c-format */
867 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
872 asection *linksec = NULL;
874 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
876 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
877 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
881 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
882 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
886 /* xgettext:c-format */
887 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
888 s->owner, elfsec, s);
892 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
895 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
896 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
899 /* xgettext:c-format */
900 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
901 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
906 /* Process section groups. */
907 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
910 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
912 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
913 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
916 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
917 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
920 /* xgettext:c-format */
921 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
927 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
928 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
934 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
936 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
937 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
938 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
939 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
941 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
943 /* xgettext:c-format */
944 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
947 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
948 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
961 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
963 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
967 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
969 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
970 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
971 if (new_name == NULL)
975 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
980 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
982 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
983 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
984 if (new_name == NULL)
987 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
991 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
992 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
995 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
996 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1002 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1004 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1007 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
1008 if (newsect == NULL)
1011 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
1012 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
1013 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1015 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1016 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1017 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1019 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1021 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
1022 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1023 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
1024 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1027 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1028 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1029 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1030 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1032 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1035 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1038 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1039 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1040 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1042 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1044 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1047 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1049 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1050 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1051 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1052 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1054 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1055 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1056 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1057 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1059 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1061 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1062 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1063 if (name [0] == '.')
1068 p = ".debug", n = 6;
1069 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
1070 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
1071 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
1072 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
1073 else if (name[1] == 'l')
1075 else if (name[1] == 's')
1077 else if (name[1] == 'z')
1078 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1081 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1082 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1086 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1087 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1088 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1089 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1090 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1091 all but one of the sections. */
1092 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1093 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1094 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1096 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1097 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1098 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1101 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1104 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1105 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1106 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1107 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1111 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1114 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1115 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1119 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1121 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1122 unsigned int i, nload;
1124 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1125 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1126 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1127 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1128 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1129 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1130 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1132 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1134 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1137 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1138 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1140 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1141 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1142 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1143 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1145 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1146 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1147 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1149 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1150 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1151 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1152 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1153 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1154 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1155 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1156 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1157 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1159 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1160 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1161 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1162 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1163 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1164 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1165 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1171 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1172 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1173 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1174 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1175 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1177 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1178 int compression_header_size;
1179 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1180 bfd_boolean compressed
1181 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1182 &compression_header_size,
1183 &uncompressed_size);
1187 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1188 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1189 action = decompress;
1192 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1193 section. Check if we should compress. */
1194 if (action == nothing)
1196 if (newsect->size != 0
1197 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1198 && compression_header_size >= 0
1199 && uncompressed_size > 0
1201 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1202 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1208 if (action == compress)
1210 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1213 /* xgettext:c-format */
1214 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1221 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1224 /* xgettext:c-format */
1225 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1231 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1234 && (action == decompress
1235 || (action == compress
1236 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1238 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1239 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1241 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1242 if (new_name == NULL)
1244 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1248 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1249 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1250 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1256 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1258 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1259 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1260 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1263 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1264 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1265 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1266 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1267 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1268 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1269 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1270 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1271 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1273 bfd_reloc_status_type
1274 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1275 arelent *reloc_entry,
1277 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1278 asection *input_section,
1280 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1282 if (output_bfd != NULL
1283 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1284 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1285 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1287 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1288 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1291 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1294 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1295 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1296 should be the same. */
1299 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1300 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1303 a->sh_type == b->sh_type
1304 && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1305 == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1306 && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
1307 && a->sh_size == b->sh_size
1308 && a->sh_entsize == b->sh_entsize
1309 /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ? */
1313 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1314 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1315 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1316 to be the correct section. */
1319 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1320 const unsigned int hint)
1322 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1325 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1327 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1328 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1329 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1330 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1333 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1335 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1337 if (oheader == NULL)
1339 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1340 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1341 multiple matches ? */
1348 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1349 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1350 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1353 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1355 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1356 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1357 const unsigned int secnum)
1359 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1360 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1361 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1362 unsigned int sh_link;
1364 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1366 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1367 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1368 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1369 matched up with the original.
1371 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1372 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1373 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1374 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1375 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1376 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1377 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1378 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1379 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1380 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1381 without any contents. */
1382 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1383 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1384 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1385 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1389 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1390 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
1391 && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1392 (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
1395 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1396 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1397 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1398 in the input bfd. */
1399 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1401 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1402 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1405 /* xgettext:c-format */
1406 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1407 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1411 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1412 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1414 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1418 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1419 if we could not find a match ? */
1421 /* xgettext:c-format */
1422 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1425 if (iheader->sh_info)
1427 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1428 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1430 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1432 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1434 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1435 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1438 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1439 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1441 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1443 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1448 /* xgettext:c-format */
1449 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1455 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1459 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1461 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1462 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1463 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1466 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1467 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1470 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1472 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1473 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1476 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1478 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1479 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1480 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1482 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1483 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1484 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1485 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1487 /* Copy object attributes. */
1488 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1490 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1493 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1495 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1496 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1499 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1501 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1502 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1503 files. See below for more details. */
1505 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1506 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1509 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1510 fields have already been initialised. */
1511 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1512 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1515 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1516 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1517 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1519 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1521 if (iheader == NULL)
1524 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1525 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1526 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1527 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1529 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1530 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1531 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1532 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1533 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1534 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1539 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1542 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1543 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1544 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1545 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1547 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1549 if (iheader == NULL)
1552 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1553 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1554 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1556 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1557 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1558 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1559 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1560 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1561 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1562 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1563 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1564 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1565 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1567 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1572 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1574 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1575 with a NULL input section. */
1576 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
1577 bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
1585 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1590 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1591 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1592 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1593 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1594 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1595 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1596 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1597 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1598 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1599 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1600 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1601 default: pt = NULL; break;
1606 /* Print out the program headers. */
1609 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1611 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1612 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1614 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1616 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1621 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1622 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1623 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1625 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1630 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1633 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1634 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1635 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1636 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1637 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1638 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1639 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1640 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1641 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1642 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1643 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1644 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1645 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1646 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1647 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1648 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1649 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1654 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1657 unsigned int elfsec;
1658 unsigned long shlink;
1659 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1661 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1663 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1665 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1668 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1669 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1671 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1673 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1674 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1677 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1678 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1680 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1681 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1683 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1685 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1686 const char *name = "";
1688 bfd_boolean stringp;
1689 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1691 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1693 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1700 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1701 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1703 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1705 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1710 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1711 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1712 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1713 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1714 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1715 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1716 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1717 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1718 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1719 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1720 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1721 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1722 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1723 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1724 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1725 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1726 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1727 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1728 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1729 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1730 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1731 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1732 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1733 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1734 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1735 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1736 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1737 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1738 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1739 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1740 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1741 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1742 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1743 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1744 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1745 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1746 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1747 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1748 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1749 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1750 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1751 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1752 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1753 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1754 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1755 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1756 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1757 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1758 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1759 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1760 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1761 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1762 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1763 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1764 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1765 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1766 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1767 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1770 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1774 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1779 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1781 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1784 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1793 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1794 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1796 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1800 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1802 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1804 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1805 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1807 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1808 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1809 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1810 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1812 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1815 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1819 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1825 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1827 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1829 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1830 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1832 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1834 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1835 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1836 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1837 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1838 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1839 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1851 /* Get version string. */
1854 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1855 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1857 const char *version_string = NULL;
1858 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1859 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1861 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1863 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1864 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1867 version_string = "";
1868 else if (vernum == 1
1869 && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
1870 || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
1872 version_string = "Base";
1873 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1875 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1878 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1880 version_string = _("<corrupt>");
1881 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1885 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1887 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1889 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1891 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1898 return version_string;
1901 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1904 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1907 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1909 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1912 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1913 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1915 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1916 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1917 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1918 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1920 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1922 const char *section_name;
1923 const char *name = NULL;
1924 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1925 unsigned char st_other;
1927 const char *version_string;
1930 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1932 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1933 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1934 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1938 name = symbol->name;
1939 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1942 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1943 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1944 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1945 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1946 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1947 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1948 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1950 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1951 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1953 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1954 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1960 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1965 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1966 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1971 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1972 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1977 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1978 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1979 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1981 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1983 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1986 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1992 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1994 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1997 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1999 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
2000 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
2001 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2003 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
2004 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
2005 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
2006 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
2008 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2013 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
2014 sections, with each the string indices pointing to the next in the
2015 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
2016 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2017 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2018 can expect to recurse at least once.
2020 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2021 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2023 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
2024 sections_being_created = NULL;
2025 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2027 /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
2028 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
2029 bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
2030 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2032 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2035 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2038 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2041 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2042 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2043 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2048 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2049 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2052 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2055 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2056 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2057 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2058 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2059 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2060 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2061 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2062 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2063 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2064 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2067 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2068 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2071 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2073 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2074 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2075 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2078 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2079 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2080 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2082 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2087 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2089 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2091 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2093 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2094 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2095 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2096 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2098 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2099 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2103 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2105 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2106 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2108 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2109 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2111 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2119 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2120 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2123 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2126 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2128 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2130 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2131 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2132 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2137 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2138 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2139 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2142 /* xgettext:c-format */
2143 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2144 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2148 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2149 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2150 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2151 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2153 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2154 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2155 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2156 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2157 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2159 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2160 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2161 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2165 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2166 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2167 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2169 elf_section_list * entry;
2170 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2172 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2173 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2176 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2177 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2179 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2181 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2182 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2187 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2189 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2191 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2192 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2197 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2198 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2202 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2203 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2206 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2209 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2211 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2214 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2215 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2216 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2221 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2222 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2223 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2226 /* xgettext:c-format */
2227 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2228 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2232 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2233 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2234 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2235 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2237 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2238 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2239 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2242 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2244 elf_section_list * entry;
2246 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2247 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2250 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
2253 entry->ndx = shindex;
2255 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2256 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2257 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2261 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2262 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2265 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2267 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2268 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2272 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2275 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2276 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2280 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2283 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2284 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2285 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2286 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2288 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2293 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2294 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2295 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2296 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2298 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2300 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2301 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2303 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2304 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2306 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2309 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2311 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2313 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2314 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2318 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2323 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2325 asection *target_sect;
2326 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2327 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2328 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2331 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2332 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2335 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2336 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2339 /* xgettext:c-format */
2340 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2341 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2342 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2347 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2348 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2349 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2350 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2351 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2352 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2353 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2355 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2356 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2357 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2358 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2364 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2366 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2367 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2378 hdr->sh_link = found;
2381 /* Get the symbol table. */
2382 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2383 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2384 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2387 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2388 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2389 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2390 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2391 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2392 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2393 sh_link points to the null section. */
2394 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2395 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2396 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2397 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2398 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2399 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2401 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2406 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2409 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2410 if (target_sect == NULL)
2413 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2414 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2415 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2417 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2419 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2422 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2427 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2428 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2429 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2430 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2431 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2432 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2433 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2434 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2435 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2437 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2438 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2440 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2444 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2445 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2446 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2447 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2450 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2451 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2454 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2455 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2456 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2459 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2460 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2461 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2462 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2469 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2472 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2478 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2479 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2480 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2482 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2484 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2488 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2489 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2492 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2494 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2495 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2496 for applications? */
2498 /* xgettext:c-format */
2499 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2500 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2503 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2504 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2509 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2510 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2511 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2513 /* xgettext:c-format */
2514 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2515 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2516 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2518 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2519 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2520 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2521 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2522 be rejected with an error message. */
2524 /* xgettext:c-format */
2525 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2526 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2529 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2530 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2535 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2537 /* xgettext:c-format */
2538 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2539 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2547 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2548 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2549 if (-- nesting == 0)
2551 sections_being_created = NULL;
2552 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2557 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2560 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2562 unsigned long r_symndx)
2564 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2566 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2568 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2569 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2570 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2572 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2573 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2574 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2577 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2579 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2582 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2585 return &cache->sym[ent];
2588 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2592 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2594 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2596 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2599 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2601 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2602 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2605 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2607 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2608 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2611 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2613 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2614 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2615 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2616 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2617 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2618 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2619 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2620 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2621 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2622 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2623 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2624 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2625 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2626 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2629 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2631 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2632 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2633 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2636 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2638 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2639 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2640 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2641 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2642 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2643 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2644 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2645 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2646 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2647 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2650 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2652 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2653 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2656 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2658 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2659 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2661 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2664 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2666 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2667 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2670 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2672 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2673 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2674 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2677 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2679 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2680 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2681 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2684 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2686 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2690 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2693 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2695 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2696 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2697 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2698 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2699 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2700 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2701 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2704 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2706 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2707 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2708 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2709 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2712 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2714 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2715 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2716 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2717 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2718 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2721 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2723 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2724 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2725 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2727 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2728 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2729 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2730 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2733 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2735 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2737 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2739 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2740 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2741 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2747 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2750 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2751 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2752 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2758 len = strlen (name);
2760 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2763 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2765 if (len < prefix_len)
2767 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2770 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2771 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2773 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2775 if (suffix_len == 0)
2777 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2778 && (suffix_len == -2
2779 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2785 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2787 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2788 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2798 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2799 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2802 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2803 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2805 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2806 if (sec->name == NULL)
2809 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2810 spec = bed->special_sections;
2813 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2814 bed->special_sections,
2820 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2823 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2824 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2827 spec = special_sections[i];
2832 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2836 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2838 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2839 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2840 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2842 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2845 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2849 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2852 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2853 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2854 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2856 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2857 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2858 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2859 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2860 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2861 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2862 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2863 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2864 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2865 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2866 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2868 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2871 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2872 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2873 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2875 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2876 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2880 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2883 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2885 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2886 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2887 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2888 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2890 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2891 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2892 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2893 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2894 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2895 of combined data+bss.
2897 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2898 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2899 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2900 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2901 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2906 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2907 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2909 const char *type_name)
2917 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2918 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2919 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2921 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2923 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2924 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2925 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2928 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2929 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2930 if (newsect == NULL)
2932 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2933 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2934 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2935 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2936 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2937 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2938 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2940 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2941 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2942 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2944 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2946 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2949 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2951 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2955 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2959 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2960 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2961 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2964 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2965 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2966 if (newsect == NULL)
2968 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2969 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2970 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2971 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2972 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2973 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2974 align = hdr->p_align;
2975 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2976 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2978 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2979 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2980 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2981 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2982 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2983 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2984 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2986 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2987 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2988 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2990 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2991 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2998 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
3000 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3002 switch (hdr->p_type)
3005 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
3008 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
3011 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
3014 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
3017 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3019 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3025 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3028 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3030 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3031 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3035 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3038 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3041 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3042 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3043 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3047 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3051 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3053 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3055 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3056 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3059 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3063 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3064 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3065 const char *sec_name,
3066 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3068 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3069 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3073 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3075 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3077 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3083 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3084 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3085 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3089 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3090 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3091 const char *sec_name,
3092 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3093 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3095 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3096 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3098 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3099 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3100 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3102 if (delay_st_name_p)
3103 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3104 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3107 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3108 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3109 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3110 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3111 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3112 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3113 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3114 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3115 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3120 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3123 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3125 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3126 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3128 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3131 struct fake_section_arg
3133 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3137 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3140 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3142 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3143 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3144 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3145 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3146 unsigned int sh_type;
3147 const char *name = asect->name;
3148 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3152 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3157 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3161 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3162 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3163 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3167 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3169 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3171 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3172 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3173 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3174 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3177 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3179 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3180 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3182 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3183 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3187 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3188 if (new_name == NULL)
3196 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3198 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3199 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3200 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3201 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3202 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3203 if (new_name == NULL)
3208 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3213 if (delay_st_name_p)
3214 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3218 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3220 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3227 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3229 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3230 || asect->user_set_vma)
3231 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
3233 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3235 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3236 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3237 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3238 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3239 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3242 /* xgettext:c-format */
3243 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3244 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3248 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
3249 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3250 copy_private_section_data. */
3252 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3253 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3255 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3257 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3258 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3260 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3262 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3263 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3264 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3265 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3266 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3268 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3269 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3270 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3271 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3273 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3274 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3277 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3288 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3289 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3290 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3291 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3295 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3299 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3303 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3307 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3308 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3312 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3313 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3316 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3317 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3320 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3321 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3322 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3323 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3325 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3326 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3328 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3329 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3332 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3333 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3334 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3335 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3337 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3338 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3340 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3341 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3345 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3349 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3353 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3354 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3355 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3356 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3357 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3358 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3359 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3361 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3362 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3364 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3365 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3366 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3367 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3368 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3370 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3371 if (asect->size == 0
3372 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3374 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3376 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3379 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3380 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3381 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3385 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3386 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3388 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3389 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3390 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3391 create the other. */
3392 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3394 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3397 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3398 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3399 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3400 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3402 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3403 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3404 FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3409 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3410 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3411 TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3417 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3419 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3429 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3430 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3431 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3432 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3438 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3440 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3441 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3442 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3446 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3447 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3448 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3449 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3452 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3454 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3455 asection *elt, *first;
3459 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3461 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3465 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3467 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3469 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3471 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3472 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3476 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3477 elf_section_syms. */
3478 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3479 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3481 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3483 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3485 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3486 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3487 set until all local symbols are output. */
3489 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3490 unsigned long symndx;
3491 unsigned long extsymoff;
3492 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3494 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3495 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3496 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3497 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3498 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3499 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3501 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3503 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3505 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3506 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3508 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3509 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3510 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3511 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3513 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3516 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3518 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3521 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3523 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3524 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3525 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3532 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3534 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3535 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3536 start of the input section group. */
3537 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3539 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3540 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3541 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3542 directives, not that it matters. */
3549 s = s->output_section;
3551 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3553 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3554 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3556 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3558 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3559 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3561 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3563 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3565 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3567 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3568 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3570 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3572 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3575 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3577 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3583 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3585 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3588 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3589 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3590 relocations apply. */
3593 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3595 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3596 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3597 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3598 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3603 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3609 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3612 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3615 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3620 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3622 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3623 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3626 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3627 name = reloc_sec->name;
3628 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3631 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3634 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3635 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3636 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3639 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3640 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3641 in here too, while we're at it. */
3644 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3646 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3648 unsigned int section_number;
3649 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3650 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3651 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3655 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3657 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3658 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3660 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3662 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3663 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3665 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3667 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3669 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3671 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3672 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3673 abfd->section_count--;
3676 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3679 /* Count relocations. */
3680 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3683 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3684 if (reloc_count == 0)
3685 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3688 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3690 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3692 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3693 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3694 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3695 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3698 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3699 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3700 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3707 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3708 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3709 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3715 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3716 || (link_info == NULL
3717 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3721 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3722 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3723 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3725 elf_section_list * entry;
3727 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3729 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3730 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3731 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3733 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3734 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3735 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3738 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3739 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3742 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3743 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3744 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3746 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3748 /* xgettext:c-format */
3749 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3750 abfd, section_number);
3754 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3755 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3757 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3759 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3760 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3761 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3764 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3765 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3766 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3768 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3772 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3774 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3777 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3778 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3780 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3781 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3782 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3783 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3785 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3786 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3789 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3793 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3795 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3796 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3797 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3798 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3799 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3801 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3803 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3804 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3805 the relocation entries apply. */
3806 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3808 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3809 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3810 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3812 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3814 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3815 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3816 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3819 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3820 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3822 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3825 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3826 if (link_info != NULL)
3828 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3829 if (discarded_section (s))
3833 /* xgettext:c-format */
3834 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3835 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3836 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3838 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3839 size as the discarded one. */
3840 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3843 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3849 s = s->output_section;
3850 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3854 /* Handle objcopy. */
3855 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3858 /* xgettext:c-format */
3859 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3860 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3861 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3862 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3865 s = s->output_section;
3867 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3872 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3873 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3874 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3876 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3877 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3878 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3879 bed->link_order_error_handler
3880 /* xgettext:c-format */
3881 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
3886 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3890 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3891 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3892 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3893 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3894 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3895 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3896 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3898 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3900 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3903 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3904 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3909 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3910 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3911 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3912 field to point to this section. */
3913 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3914 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3919 len = strlen (sec->name);
3920 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3923 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3924 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3925 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3929 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3931 /* This is a .stab section. */
3932 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3933 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3934 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3941 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3942 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3943 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3944 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3946 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3948 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3951 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3952 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3953 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3954 the version strings. */
3955 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3956 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3958 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3963 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3964 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3965 this hash table or version table is for. */
3966 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3968 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3972 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3976 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3977 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3978 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3984 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3986 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3987 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3988 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3989 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3991 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3992 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3993 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3996 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
3997 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
3998 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
3999 the beginning of that array.
4001 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4004 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4005 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
4007 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
4009 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
4011 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
4012 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
4013 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4015 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4018 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
4021 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4023 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4026 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4029 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4034 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4035 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4038 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4040 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4045 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4048 if (sym->section == NULL)
4051 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4052 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4053 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4054 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4055 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4056 || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4057 && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4058 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4059 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4062 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4063 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4066 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4068 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4069 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4070 asymbol **sect_syms;
4071 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4072 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4073 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4074 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4075 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4081 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4085 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4087 if (max_index < asect->index)
4088 max_index = asect->index;
4092 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
4093 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4095 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4096 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4098 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4099 decided to output. */
4100 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4102 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4104 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4106 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4107 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4109 asection *sec = sym->section;
4111 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4112 sec = sec->output_section;
4114 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4118 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4119 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4121 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4123 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4127 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4128 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4129 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4130 at least in that case. */
4131 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4133 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4135 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4142 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4143 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
4144 sizeof (asymbol *));
4146 if (new_syms == NULL)
4149 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4151 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4154 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4155 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4156 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4161 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4163 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4165 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4167 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4170 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4171 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4174 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4176 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4180 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4182 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4186 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4187 ELF data structure. */
4189 static inline file_ptr
4190 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4192 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4195 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4196 required section alignment. */
4199 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4203 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4204 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4205 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4206 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4207 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4208 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4209 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4213 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4214 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4215 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4218 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4219 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4221 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4222 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4224 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4225 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4226 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4228 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4231 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4232 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4233 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4235 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
4238 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
4239 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
4241 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4242 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4243 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4247 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4250 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4251 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4252 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4253 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4257 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4258 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4260 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4265 if (link_info == NULL)
4267 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4272 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4273 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
4274 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4275 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4276 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4277 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4278 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4279 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4280 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4281 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4282 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4284 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4290 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4292 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4294 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4295 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4297 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4299 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4300 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4301 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4302 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4305 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4306 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4308 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4310 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4312 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4313 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4315 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4318 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4323 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4324 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4326 static bfd_size_type
4327 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4331 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4333 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4334 and one for data. */
4337 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4338 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4340 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4341 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4342 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4347 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4349 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4353 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4355 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4359 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4361 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4365 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4367 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4371 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4373 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4374 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4376 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4378 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
4379 for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
4380 gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
4381 (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4382 each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
4383 so we check whether the sections are correctly
4385 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4386 while (s->next != NULL
4387 && s->next->alignment_power == 2
4388 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4389 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
4394 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4396 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4398 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4404 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4406 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4408 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4409 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4410 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4411 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4413 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4417 /* xgettext:c-format */
4418 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIN section `%pA' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
4419 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4422 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4423 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4424 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4429 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4430 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4434 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4440 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4443 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4446 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4448 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4449 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4451 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4457 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4458 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4465 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4467 static struct elf_segment_map *
4468 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4469 asection **sections,
4474 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4479 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4480 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4481 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4485 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4486 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4487 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4488 m->count = to - from;
4490 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4492 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4493 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4494 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4500 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4503 struct elf_segment_map *
4504 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4506 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4508 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4509 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4513 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4515 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4520 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4523 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4524 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4525 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4527 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4528 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4530 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4531 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4532 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4533 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4535 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4538 unsigned int i, new_count;
4540 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4542 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4543 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4544 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4546 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4550 (*m)->count = new_count;
4552 if (remove_empty_load
4553 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4555 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4561 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4562 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4564 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4571 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4572 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4574 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4577 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4580 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4581 asection **sections = NULL;
4582 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4583 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4585 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4588 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4590 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4594 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4595 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4598 unsigned int phdr_index;
4599 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4601 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4602 bfd_boolean writable;
4603 bfd_boolean executable;
4605 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4606 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4607 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4609 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4610 bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
4612 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4614 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4615 sizeof (asection *));
4616 if (sections == NULL)
4619 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4620 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4622 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4623 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4626 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4628 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4632 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4633 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4634 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4637 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4640 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4642 /* Build the mapping. */
4647 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4648 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4650 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4651 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4653 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4654 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4658 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4660 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4661 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4662 linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
4666 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4667 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4671 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4679 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4680 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4681 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4685 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4686 /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4687 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4688 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4689 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4693 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4695 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4698 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4699 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4700 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4701 program headers we will need. */
4704 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4706 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4707 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4708 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4709 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4710 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4711 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4712 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4713 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4715 /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
4716 present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
4717 program. Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
4718 If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
4719 not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
4720 force the inclusion if we can... */
4721 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4722 && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
4723 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4725 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4729 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4732 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4736 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4739 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4741 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4742 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4743 new_segment = FALSE;
4745 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4747 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4748 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4752 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4753 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4755 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4756 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4759 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4760 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4761 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4763 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4764 pages onto the same memory page. */
4765 new_segment = FALSE;
4767 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4768 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4769 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4770 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4771 section can be included in the current segment. */
4772 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4773 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4774 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4775 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4777 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4778 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4781 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4782 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4784 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4785 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4786 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4787 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4790 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4792 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4793 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4794 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4795 new_segment = FALSE;
4797 else if (info != NULL
4798 && info->separate_code
4799 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4804 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4806 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4812 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4813 new_segment = FALSE;
4816 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4817 if (last_hdr != NULL
4819 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4821 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4827 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4829 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4832 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4833 last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4837 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4838 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4840 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4847 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4852 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4858 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4859 last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4861 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4864 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4866 if (last_hdr != NULL
4867 && (i - phdr_index != 1
4868 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4870 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4878 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4881 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4888 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4889 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4890 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4891 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4892 in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4894 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4896 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4897 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4902 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4903 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4904 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4906 if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4907 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4908 && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4909 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4915 amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4916 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4920 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4924 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4925 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4928 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4929 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4933 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4939 if (first_mbind == NULL
4940 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
4944 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4947 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4948 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4949 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4954 m->count = tls_count;
4955 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4957 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4959 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4961 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4964 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4967 while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4969 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4971 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
4975 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
4978 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4989 if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4990 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4991 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
4992 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4993 <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
4995 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4996 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
4997 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4999 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
5002 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5003 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5007 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5008 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
5010 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5012 m->p_flags = p_flags;
5018 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5020 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5021 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5022 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5024 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5025 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5029 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5031 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5037 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5039 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5040 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5044 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5045 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5046 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5047 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5048 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5049 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5051 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5052 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5059 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5061 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5063 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5065 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5066 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5069 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5070 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5071 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5074 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5079 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5082 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5083 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5087 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5094 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5097 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5100 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5102 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5107 if (sections != NULL)
5112 /* Sort sections by address. */
5115 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5117 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5118 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5119 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5121 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5122 place the section into a segment. */
5123 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5125 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5128 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5129 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5130 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5132 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5135 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5137 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5143 /* If the indices are the same, do not return 0
5144 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
5145 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
5146 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5151 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5156 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5157 before others at the same address. */
5159 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5160 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5167 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5170 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5172 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5173 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5174 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5175 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5176 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5179 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5180 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5182 /* In other words, something like:
5184 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5185 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5186 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5187 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5189 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5191 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5194 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5196 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5197 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5199 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5203 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5206 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5211 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5212 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5213 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5214 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5215 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5216 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5218 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5219 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5223 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5224 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5225 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5231 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5236 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5238 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5241 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5246 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5247 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5251 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5252 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5254 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5255 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5256 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5257 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5259 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5260 unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
5263 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
5265 if (link_info == NULL
5266 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5270 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5274 header_pad = m->header_size;
5279 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5280 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5284 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5285 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5286 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5289 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5291 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5292 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5294 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5295 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5299 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5303 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5304 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5305 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5306 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5307 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5309 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5310 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5311 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5312 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
5314 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
5316 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
5317 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
5318 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5323 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5324 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5326 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5327 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5328 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
5334 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
5336 m = m->next, p++, j++)
5340 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5342 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5343 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5344 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5345 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5346 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5348 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5349 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5350 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5353 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5354 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5355 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5356 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5357 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5358 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5359 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5364 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5366 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5367 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5368 else if (m->count == 0)
5371 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5373 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5374 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5376 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5377 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5378 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5379 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5380 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5381 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5382 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5384 if (m->p_align_valid)
5385 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5387 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5390 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5391 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5392 else if (m->count == 0)
5393 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5397 no_contents = FALSE;
5399 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5402 bfd_size_type align;
5403 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5405 if (m->p_align_valid)
5409 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5411 unsigned int secalign;
5413 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
5414 if (secalign > align_power)
5415 align_power = secalign;
5417 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5418 if (align < maxpagesize)
5419 align = maxpagesize;
5422 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5423 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5424 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5425 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5426 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5427 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5429 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5432 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5433 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5435 no_contents = FALSE;
5439 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5441 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5442 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5444 if (pt_load_count > 1
5445 && bed->no_page_alias
5446 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5447 && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
5448 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5452 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5453 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5454 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5455 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5456 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5457 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5458 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5459 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5464 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5465 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5466 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5468 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5471 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5472 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5474 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5477 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5478 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5479 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5480 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5486 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5488 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5490 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5491 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5494 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5495 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5496 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5499 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5500 " try linking with -N"),
5502 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5507 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5512 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5514 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5517 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5519 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5523 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5524 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5525 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5529 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5530 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5533 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5534 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5538 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5539 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5541 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5547 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5549 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5550 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5554 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5555 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5556 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5557 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5558 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5559 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5562 bfd_size_type align;
5563 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5566 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5567 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5569 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5570 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5571 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5572 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5573 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5574 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5576 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5577 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5578 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5579 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5583 || p_end < p_start))
5586 /* xgettext:c-format */
5587 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5588 abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start, (uint64_t) p_end);
5592 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5594 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5596 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5598 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5599 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5601 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5602 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5606 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5610 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5612 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5616 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5617 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5618 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5624 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5633 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5635 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5636 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5637 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5639 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5640 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5641 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5643 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5644 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5645 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5646 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5647 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5648 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5650 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5652 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5655 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5657 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5658 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5659 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5660 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5661 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5662 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5664 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5666 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5667 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5669 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5671 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5672 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5675 if (align > p->p_align
5676 && !m->p_align_valid
5677 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5678 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5682 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5685 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5687 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5694 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5695 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5696 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5698 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5700 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5701 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5702 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5703 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5704 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5705 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5707 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5712 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5714 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5717 sec = m->sections[i];
5718 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5719 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5720 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5723 /* xgettext:c-format */
5724 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5726 print_segment_map (m);
5732 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5736 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5739 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5740 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5742 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5743 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5744 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5745 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5746 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5747 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5748 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5749 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5750 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5754 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5755 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5756 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5757 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5759 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5762 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5763 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5764 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5765 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5766 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5767 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5769 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5771 /* xgettext:c-format */
5772 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5774 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5776 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5777 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5778 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5779 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5782 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5784 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5787 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5788 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5789 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5790 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5791 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5792 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5793 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5794 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5795 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5796 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5797 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5799 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5802 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5803 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5807 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5809 hdrs_segment = NULL;
5810 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5811 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5814 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5817 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5819 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5820 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5822 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5824 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5825 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5826 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5829 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5830 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5835 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5837 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5838 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5839 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5841 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5842 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5843 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5844 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5846 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5847 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5848 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5849 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5852 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5853 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5854 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5856 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5857 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5866 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5867 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5871 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5872 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5875 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5876 hash->def_regular = 1;
5881 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5883 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5888 if (link_info != NULL)
5890 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5891 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
5892 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
5893 start = link_info->relro_start;
5894 end = link_info->relro_end;
5896 else if (m->count != 0)
5898 if (!m->p_size_valid)
5900 start = m->sections[0]->vma;
5901 end = start + m->p_size;
5912 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5913 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5916 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
5918 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5920 lm = lm->next, lp++)
5922 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5924 && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
5925 + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
5926 ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size
5928 && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
5934 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
5935 for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
5937 asection *s = lm->sections[i];
5946 p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma;
5947 p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma;
5948 p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
5949 p->p_memsz = end - p->p_vaddr;
5950 p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
5952 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
5953 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
5954 In cases where the end does not match any
5955 loaded section (for instance is in file
5956 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
5957 the end of loaded section contents. */
5958 if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
5959 p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
5961 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
5962 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
5963 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
5964 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5965 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
5967 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5969 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5975 if (link_info != NULL)
5978 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5980 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5982 if (m->p_size_valid)
5983 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5985 else if (m->count != 0)
5989 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5990 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5991 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5993 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
5994 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
5995 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
6001 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
6003 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6005 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6006 "and/or program header"),
6007 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
6012 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
6013 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
6015 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
6016 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6017 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6019 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6026 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
6028 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
6029 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6030 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
6032 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
6034 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
6035 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6036 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
6040 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6045 static elf_section_list *
6046 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6048 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6054 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6055 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6056 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6058 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6059 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
6060 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
6061 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
6062 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
6063 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
6064 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6066 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6069 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6070 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6072 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6073 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6074 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6076 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6077 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6079 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6080 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6081 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6085 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6086 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6088 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6089 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6090 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6091 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6093 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6096 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6097 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6098 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6099 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
6100 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6101 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6102 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6103 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6104 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6105 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6107 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6110 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6113 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6119 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6120 assignment of sections to segments. */
6121 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6124 /* And for non-load sections. */
6125 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6128 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
6130 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6134 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
6135 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6137 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6138 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6139 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6141 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6142 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6143 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6144 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6145 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6147 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6148 segments is non-zero. */
6150 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6153 /* Write out the program headers. */
6154 alloc = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6158 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
6159 be loaded into memory. FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
6160 really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
6161 message. Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
6162 in the program header table. But this version of the check should
6163 catch all real world use cases.
6165 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6166 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6167 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6168 changed or the programs updated. */
6170 && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
6171 && (bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr == NULL
6172 || !bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr,
6174 && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
6175 && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
6176 || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz
6177 < tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
6179 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
6180 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
6181 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
6182 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
6183 " by LOAD segment"),
6188 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
6189 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6197 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
6199 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6200 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6201 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6203 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6205 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6206 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6209 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6211 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6212 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6213 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6214 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6216 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6217 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6218 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6219 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6221 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6222 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6223 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6224 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6225 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6226 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6228 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6230 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6232 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6233 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6236 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6237 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6238 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6239 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6240 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6241 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6242 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6243 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6245 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6248 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6249 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6251 /* No program header, for now. */
6252 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6253 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6254 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6256 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6257 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6258 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6260 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
6261 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
6262 /* It all happens later. */
6266 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6267 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6270 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6271 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6272 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6273 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6274 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6275 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6276 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6277 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6278 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6284 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6285 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6288 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6291 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6292 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6293 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6294 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6296 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6298 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6299 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6300 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6303 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6305 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6306 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6307 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6309 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6313 const char *name = sec->name;
6314 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6316 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6317 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6321 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6322 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6324 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6325 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6327 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6328 if (new_name == NULL)
6332 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6333 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6336 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6338 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6340 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6342 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6347 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6352 /* Update section size and contents. */
6353 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6354 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6355 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6357 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6364 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6366 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6367 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6368 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6369 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6371 /* Place the section headers. */
6372 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6373 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6374 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6375 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6376 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6377 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6383 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6385 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6386 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6388 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6389 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6391 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6392 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6395 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6398 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6402 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6405 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6406 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6407 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6409 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6410 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6411 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6412 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6413 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6415 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6417 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6419 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6420 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6425 /* Write out the section header names. */
6426 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6427 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6428 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6429 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6432 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
6433 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
6435 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6438 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6439 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6440 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6446 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6448 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6449 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6452 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6455 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6457 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6458 unsigned int sec_index;
6460 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6461 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6462 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6464 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6465 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6466 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6467 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6468 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6469 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6471 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6473 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6474 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6476 int retval = sec_index;
6478 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6482 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6483 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6488 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6492 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6494 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6496 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6498 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6499 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6500 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6501 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6502 input sections rather than the output section. */
6503 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6504 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6505 && asym_ptr->section)
6510 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6511 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6512 sec = sec->output_section;
6513 if (sec->owner == abfd
6514 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6515 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6516 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6519 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6523 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6524 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6526 /* xgettext:c-format */
6527 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6528 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6529 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6536 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6537 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6545 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6548 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6550 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6551 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6552 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6553 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6554 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6557 unsigned int num_segments;
6558 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6559 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6560 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6561 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6562 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6563 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6565 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6566 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6569 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6571 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6572 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6574 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6575 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6576 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6577 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6579 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6580 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6581 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6582 ? section->size : 0)
6584 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6585 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6586 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6587 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6588 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6589 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6591 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6592 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6593 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6594 (section->lma >= base \
6595 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6596 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6598 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6599 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6600 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6601 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6602 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6603 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6604 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6606 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6608 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6610 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6614 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6615 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6616 p_memsz set to 0. */
6617 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6619 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6620 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6621 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6622 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6624 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6625 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6626 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6628 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6629 A section will be included if:
6630 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6631 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6632 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6634 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6635 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6636 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6637 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6638 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6639 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6640 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6641 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6642 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6643 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6644 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6645 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6646 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6647 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6648 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6649 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6650 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6651 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6652 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6653 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6654 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6655 || (segment->p_paddr \
6656 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6657 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6658 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6660 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6662 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6663 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6664 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6665 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6666 && section->output_section != NULL)
6668 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6669 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6670 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6672 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6673 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6674 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6675 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6676 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6678 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6679 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6680 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6681 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6682 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6684 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6685 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6686 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6688 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6689 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6690 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6691 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6692 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6693 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6696 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6698 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6702 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6703 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6704 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6705 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6706 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6711 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6713 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6714 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6715 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6717 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6718 assignment code will work. */
6719 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6723 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6725 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6726 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6727 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6731 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6732 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6734 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6736 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6737 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6740 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6741 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6743 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6745 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6746 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6748 if (extra_length > 0)
6750 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6751 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6754 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6756 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6758 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6763 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6765 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6766 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6768 if (extra_length > 0)
6770 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6771 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6774 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6779 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6780 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6784 unsigned int section_count;
6785 asection **sections;
6786 asection *output_section;
6788 asection *matching_lma;
6789 asection *suggested_lma;
6792 asection *first_section;
6794 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6797 first_section = NULL;
6798 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6799 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6801 section = section->next)
6803 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6804 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6805 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6807 if (first_section == NULL)
6808 first_section = section;
6809 if (section->output_section != NULL)
6814 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6815 all of the sections we have selected. */
6816 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6817 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6818 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6822 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6823 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6825 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6826 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6827 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6829 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6830 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6832 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6834 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6835 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6838 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6839 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6840 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6841 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6842 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6844 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6846 map->includes_phdrs =
6847 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6848 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6849 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6850 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6852 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6853 phdr_included = TRUE;
6856 if (section_count == 0)
6858 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6859 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6860 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6861 a warning is produced.
6862 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
6863 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
6864 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
6865 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6866 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
6867 /* xgettext:c-format */
6869 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
6870 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
6871 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
6874 *pointer_to_map = map;
6875 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6880 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6881 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6882 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6883 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6885 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6886 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6889 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6890 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6891 of the first section.
6893 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6894 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6895 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6896 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6897 have to be created to contain the other sections.
6899 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6900 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6901 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6902 or segments to contain the other sections.
6904 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6905 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6906 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6908 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6909 if (sections == NULL)
6912 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6913 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6914 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6915 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6916 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6919 matching_lma = NULL;
6920 suggested_lma = NULL;
6922 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
6924 section = section->next)
6926 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6928 output_section = section->output_section;
6930 sections[j++] = section;
6932 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6933 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6934 correct value. Note - some backends require that
6935 p_paddr be left as zero. */
6937 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6938 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6940 && output_section->lma != 0
6941 && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
6942 + (map->includes_filehdr
6943 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
6944 + (map->includes_phdrs
6945 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
6947 output_section->alignment_power)
6948 == output_section->vma))
6949 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6951 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6952 LMA address of the output section. */
6953 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6954 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6955 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6956 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6958 if (matching_lma == NULL
6959 || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
6960 matching_lma = output_section;
6962 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6963 then it does not overlap any other section within that
6965 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6967 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
6968 suggested_lma = output_section;
6970 if (j == section_count)
6975 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6977 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6979 if (isec == section_count)
6981 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6982 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6983 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6984 program header in the input BFD. */
6985 map->count = section_count;
6986 *pointer_to_map = map;
6987 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6990 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6991 && matching_lma->lma != map->p_paddr
6992 && !map->includes_filehdr
6993 && !map->includes_phdrs)
6994 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
6995 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
6997 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma->lma - map->p_paddr;
7004 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7005 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7006 section fitted, the first section. */
7007 if (matching_lma == NULL)
7008 matching_lma = suggested_lma;
7010 map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma;
7012 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7013 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7014 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7016 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7018 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7019 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7020 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7021 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7022 offset when we know the correct value. */
7023 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7024 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7027 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7029 bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
7030 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7031 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7032 first section lma, but there may have been some
7033 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7034 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7035 the same alignment. */
7036 if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
7037 align = segment->p_align;
7038 map->p_paddr &= -align;
7042 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7043 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7044 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7045 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7046 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7047 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7053 suggested_lma = NULL;
7055 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7056 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7058 section = sections[j];
7060 if (section == NULL)
7063 output_section = section->output_section;
7065 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7067 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
7068 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7070 if (map->count == 0)
7072 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7073 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7075 if (align_power (map->p_paddr
7076 + (map->includes_filehdr
7077 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7078 + (map->includes_phdrs
7079 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7081 output_section->alignment_power)
7082 != output_section->lma)
7089 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7091 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7092 and the start of this section is more than
7093 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7094 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7096 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7097 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7098 > output_section->lma))
7100 if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7101 suggested_lma = output_section;
7107 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7110 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
7111 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7113 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7114 suggested_lma = output_section;
7117 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
7119 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7120 *pointer_to_map = map;
7121 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7123 if (isec < section_count)
7125 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7126 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7127 and carry on looping. */
7128 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7129 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7130 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7137 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7138 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7139 not yet been assigned. */
7141 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7142 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7143 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7144 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma;
7145 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7146 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7147 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7150 while (isec < section_count);
7155 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7157 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7158 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7159 the offset if necessary. */
7160 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7164 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7167 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7168 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7169 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7171 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7172 if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
7175 = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
7176 map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
7183 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7184 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7186 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7187 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7188 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7189 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7190 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7191 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7195 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7198 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7200 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7201 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7202 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7203 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7204 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7206 unsigned int num_segments;
7207 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7208 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7210 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7213 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7215 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7216 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7217 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7218 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7219 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7222 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7224 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7228 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7233 unsigned int section_count;
7235 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7236 asection *first_section = NULL;
7237 asection *lowest_section;
7238 bfd_boolean no_contents = TRUE;
7240 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7241 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7243 section = section->next)
7245 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7246 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7248 if (first_section == NULL)
7249 first_section = section;
7250 if (elf_section_type (section) != SHT_NOBITS)
7251 no_contents = FALSE;
7256 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7257 all of the sections we have selected. */
7258 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7259 if (section_count != 0)
7260 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7261 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7265 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7268 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7269 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7270 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7271 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7272 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7273 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7274 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7275 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7277 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7278 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7280 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7281 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7282 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7283 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7284 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7286 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7287 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7290 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7291 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7292 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7293 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7295 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7296 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7298 map->includes_phdrs =
7299 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7300 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7301 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7302 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7304 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7305 phdr_included = TRUE;
7308 lowest_section = NULL;
7309 if (section_count != 0)
7311 unsigned int isec = 0;
7313 for (section = first_section;
7315 section = section->next)
7317 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7318 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7320 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7321 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7325 if (lowest_section == NULL
7326 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7327 lowest_section = section;
7329 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7330 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7331 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7332 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7334 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7335 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7337 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7338 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7339 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7341 if (isec == section_count)
7347 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
7349 /* Try to keep the space used by the headers plus any
7350 padding fixed. If there are sections with file contents
7351 in this segment then the lowest sh_offset is the best
7352 guess. Otherwise the segment only has file contents for
7353 the headers, and p_filesz is the best guess. */
7355 map->header_size = segment->p_filesz;
7357 map->header_size = lowest_section->filepos;
7360 if (!map->includes_phdrs
7361 && !map->includes_filehdr
7362 && map->p_paddr_valid)
7363 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
7364 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
7365 - segment->p_paddr);
7367 map->count = section_count;
7368 *pointer_to_map = map;
7369 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7372 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7376 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7380 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7382 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7383 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7386 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7389 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7391 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7392 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7393 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7394 asection *section, *osec;
7395 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7396 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7397 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7399 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7401 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7402 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7405 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7406 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7407 section = section->next)
7408 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7410 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7411 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7415 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7416 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7417 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7418 map in this case. */
7419 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7420 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7421 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7424 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7425 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7427 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7428 from the input BFD. */
7429 osec = section->output_section;
7431 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7433 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7434 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7435 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7437 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7438 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7440 || section->flags != osec->flags
7441 || section->lma != osec->lma
7442 || section->vma != osec->vma
7443 || section->size != osec->size
7444 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7445 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7451 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7453 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7454 section = section->next)
7456 if (!section->segment_mark)
7459 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7462 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7466 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7468 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7469 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7470 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7472 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7473 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7475 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7478 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7479 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7481 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7482 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7483 /* xgettext:c-format */
7484 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7485 PRIx64 " is too large"),
7486 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7488 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7491 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7492 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7495 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7498 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7501 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7505 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7508 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7509 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7510 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7512 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7513 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7516 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7518 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7519 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7520 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7521 that the linker clears to differ. */
7522 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7523 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7525 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7526 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7527 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7529 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7530 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7531 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7533 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7534 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7535 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7536 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7538 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7539 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7540 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7541 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7542 if ((link_info == NULL
7543 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7544 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7545 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7547 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7548 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7549 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7550 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7553 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7554 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7555 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7558 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7560 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7561 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7562 may be NULL at this point. */
7563 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7565 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7566 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7567 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7570 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7575 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7576 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7579 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7584 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7586 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7587 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7590 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7591 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7593 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7595 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7596 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7597 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7598 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7599 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7601 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7605 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7606 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7607 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7608 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7609 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7613 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7617 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7618 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7620 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7621 asection *s = first;
7622 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7626 /* If this member section is being output but the
7627 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7628 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7629 if (s->output_section != discarded
7630 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7632 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7633 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7635 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7636 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7637 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7638 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7640 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7642 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7643 && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7645 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7646 && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7649 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7655 if (discarded != NULL)
7657 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7658 adjust the input section size. */
7659 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7660 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7661 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7662 if (isec->size <= 4)
7665 isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7670 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7672 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7673 if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7675 isec->output_section->size = 0;
7676 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7685 /* Copy private header information. */
7688 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7690 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7691 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7694 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7695 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7696 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7697 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7698 already been worked out. */
7699 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7701 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7705 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7708 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7709 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7710 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7711 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7712 swap_out_syms function. */
7714 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7715 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7716 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7717 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7718 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7721 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7726 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7728 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7729 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7732 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7733 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7736 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7738 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7742 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7743 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7744 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7745 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7746 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7747 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7749 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7750 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7751 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7752 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7753 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7759 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7762 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7763 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7766 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7769 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7770 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7771 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7772 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7773 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7774 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7775 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7776 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7777 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7779 unsigned int num_locals;
7781 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7783 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7786 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7787 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7791 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7792 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7793 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7794 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7795 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7796 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7797 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7798 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7800 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7801 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7803 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7804 symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7805 * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7806 if (symstrtab == NULL)
7808 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7812 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7813 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7814 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7817 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7821 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7822 outbound_syms_index = 0;
7824 outbound_shndx = NULL;
7825 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7827 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7829 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7830 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7832 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7833 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7834 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7835 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7838 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7839 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7840 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7841 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7842 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7844 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7847 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7849 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7850 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7856 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7857 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7858 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7859 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7860 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7861 outbound_syms_index++;
7862 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7863 outbound_shndx_index++;
7867 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7868 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7870 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7871 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7873 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7874 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7875 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7876 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7879 if (!name_local_sections
7880 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7882 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7883 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7887 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7888 to get the final offset for st_name. */
7890 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7892 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7896 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7898 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7899 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7901 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7902 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7903 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7904 sym.st_size = value;
7905 if (type_ptr == NULL
7906 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7907 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7909 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7910 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7911 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7915 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7918 if (sec->output_section)
7920 value += sec->output_offset;
7921 sec = sec->output_section;
7924 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7925 if (! relocatable_p)
7927 sym.st_value = value;
7928 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7930 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7932 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7934 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7935 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7936 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7937 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7941 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7944 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7947 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7950 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7953 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7954 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7963 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7965 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7969 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7970 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7971 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7972 demand of applications. For example, it
7973 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7974 section of a symbol to be a section that is
7975 actually in the output file. */
7976 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7978 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7979 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7981 /* xgettext:c-format */
7983 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
7984 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7985 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7987 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7993 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7996 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
7998 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
7999 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
8000 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
8002 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
8004 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
8006 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
8011 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
8014 /* Processor-specific types. */
8015 if (type_ptr != NULL
8016 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8017 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8018 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8020 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8022 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8023 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8025 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8027 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8029 if (type != STT_TLS)
8031 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8032 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8033 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8035 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8036 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8038 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8040 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8041 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8045 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8046 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8049 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8051 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8053 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8054 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8055 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8057 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8060 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8063 if (type_ptr != NULL)
8065 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8066 sym.st_target_internal
8067 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8072 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8076 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8077 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8078 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8080 outbound_syms_index++;
8081 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8082 outbound_shndx_index++;
8085 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8086 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8088 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8089 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8091 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8092 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8093 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8095 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8096 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8097 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8099 + (elfsym->dest_index
8100 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8102 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8103 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8108 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8109 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8110 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8111 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8112 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8113 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8114 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8115 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8120 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8122 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8123 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8124 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8127 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8131 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8133 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8134 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8136 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8142 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8146 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8148 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8150 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8154 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8155 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8157 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8163 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8166 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8169 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8172 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8179 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8181 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8184 tblptr = section->relocation;
8185 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8186 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8190 return section->reloc_count;
8194 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8196 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8197 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8200 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8205 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8206 asymbol **allocation)
8208 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8209 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8212 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8216 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8217 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8218 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8219 dynamic reloc section. */
8222 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8227 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8229 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8233 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
8234 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8235 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8236 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8237 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8238 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
8239 * sizeof (arelent *));
8244 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8245 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8246 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8247 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8248 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8249 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8250 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8253 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8257 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8261 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8263 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8267 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8269 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8271 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8272 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8273 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8278 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8280 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8282 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8293 /* Read in the version information. */
8296 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8298 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8299 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8301 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8303 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8304 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8305 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8307 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8309 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8311 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8312 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8314 error_return_bad_verref:
8316 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8317 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8318 error_return_verref:
8319 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8320 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8324 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8325 if (contents == NULL)
8326 goto error_return_verref;
8328 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8329 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8330 goto error_return_verref;
8332 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
8333 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
8335 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8336 goto error_return_verref;
8338 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8339 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8340 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8341 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8342 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8343 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8345 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8346 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8349 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8351 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8353 iverneed->vn_filename =
8354 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8356 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8357 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8359 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8360 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8363 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8364 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
8365 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
8366 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8367 goto error_return_verref;
8370 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8371 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8372 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8374 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8375 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8376 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8377 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8379 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8381 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8382 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8383 ivernaux->vna_name);
8384 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8385 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8387 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8388 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8390 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8391 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8393 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8396 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8397 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8399 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8400 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8401 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8403 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8404 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8407 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8408 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8410 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8411 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8413 if (iverneed->vn_next
8414 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8415 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8417 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8418 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8420 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8426 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8428 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8429 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8430 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8431 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8432 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8434 unsigned int maxidx;
8435 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8437 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8439 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8441 error_return_bad_verdef:
8443 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8444 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8445 error_return_verdef:
8446 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8447 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8451 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8452 if (contents == NULL)
8453 goto error_return_verdef;
8454 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8455 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8456 goto error_return_verdef;
8458 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8459 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8460 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8461 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8462 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8463 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8465 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8466 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8468 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8470 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8472 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8474 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8475 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8476 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8477 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8479 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8482 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8483 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8484 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8486 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8487 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8490 if (default_imported_symver)
8492 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8498 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8499 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8500 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8501 goto error_return_verdef;
8503 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8505 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8506 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8507 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8509 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8510 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8513 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8515 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8516 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8518 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8519 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8521 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8523 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8524 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8527 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8528 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
8529 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
8530 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8531 goto error_return_verdef;
8535 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8536 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8538 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8539 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8540 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8541 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8543 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8545 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8546 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8547 iverdaux->vda_name);
8548 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8549 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8551 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8552 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8554 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8557 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8558 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8560 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8561 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8562 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8564 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8565 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8568 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8569 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8570 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8572 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8573 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8575 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8576 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8578 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8579 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8585 else if (default_imported_symver)
8592 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8593 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8594 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8597 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8600 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8601 if (default_imported_symver)
8603 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8604 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8606 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8608 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8609 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8610 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8611 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8613 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8615 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8616 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8617 goto error_return_verdef;
8618 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8619 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8620 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8621 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8622 goto error_return_verdef;
8624 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8625 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8631 if (contents != NULL)
8637 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8639 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8641 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8644 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8645 return &newsym->symbol;
8649 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8653 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8656 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8657 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8661 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8664 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8665 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8668 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8669 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8670 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8673 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8674 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8675 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8676 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8677 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8678 we treat such symbols as local. */
8679 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8682 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8683 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8684 These labels have the form:
8686 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8688 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8690 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8691 so we only need to match the rest. */
8692 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8694 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8698 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8700 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8702 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8703 /* A fake symbol. */
8706 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8707 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8708 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8709 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8710 other than some kind of local ? */
8727 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8728 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8735 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8736 enum bfd_architecture arch,
8737 unsigned long machine)
8739 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8740 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8741 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8742 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8743 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8746 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8749 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8750 for error reporting. */
8753 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8757 const char **filename_ptr,
8758 const char **functionname_ptr,
8759 unsigned int *line_ptr,
8760 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8764 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8765 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8766 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8767 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8768 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8769 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8770 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8773 if (!*functionname_ptr)
8774 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8775 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8780 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8781 &found, filename_ptr,
8782 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8783 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8785 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8788 if (symbols == NULL)
8791 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8792 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8799 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8802 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8803 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8805 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8806 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8807 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8808 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8811 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8812 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8813 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8814 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8815 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8818 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8819 const char **filename_ptr,
8820 const char **functionname_ptr,
8821 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8824 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8825 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8826 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8831 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8833 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8834 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8836 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8838 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8840 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8842 struct elf_segment_map *m;
8845 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8846 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8849 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8852 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8860 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8862 const void *location,
8864 bfd_size_type count)
8866 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8869 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8870 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8876 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8877 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8879 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8880 unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8881 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8882 || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8883 || contents == NULL)
8885 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8888 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8889 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8890 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8897 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8898 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8899 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8905 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8908 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8910 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8912 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8914 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8915 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8917 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8918 equivalent ELF reloc. */
8920 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8922 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8925 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8928 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8931 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8934 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8937 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8940 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8946 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8948 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8950 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8951 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8953 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8958 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8964 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8967 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8970 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8973 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8976 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8982 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8986 areloc->howto = howto;
8994 /* xgettext:c-format */
8995 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8996 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
8997 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9002 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
9004 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
9005 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
9007 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
9008 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
9009 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9012 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
9015 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9016 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9017 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9020 bfd_reloc_status_type
9021 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9022 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9023 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9024 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9025 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9027 return bfd_reloc_ok;
9030 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9031 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9032 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9033 out details about the corefile. */
9035 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9036 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
9037 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
9038 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9041 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9042 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9045 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9049 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9051 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9056 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9057 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9058 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9062 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9066 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9069 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9073 sect2->size = sect->size;
9074 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9075 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9079 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9080 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9081 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9082 such a section already exists.
9083 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9084 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9085 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9087 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9093 char *threaded_name;
9097 /* Build the section name. */
9099 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9100 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9101 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9102 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9104 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9106 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9111 sect->filepos = filepos;
9112 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9114 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9117 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9119 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9123 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9126 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9131 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9135 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9136 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9137 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9139 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9140 has already been set by another thread. */
9141 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9142 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9143 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9144 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9146 /* pr_who exists on:
9149 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9152 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9153 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9155 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9158 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9159 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9161 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9162 prstatus32_t prstat;
9164 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9165 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9166 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9168 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9169 has already been set by another thread. */
9170 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9171 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9172 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9173 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9175 /* pr_who exists on:
9178 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9181 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9182 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9184 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9187 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9190 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9191 note size (ie. data object type). */
9195 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9196 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9197 size, note->descpos + offset);
9199 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9201 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9203 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9205 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9207 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9208 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9211 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9212 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9213 data structure apart. */
9216 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9218 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9221 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9222 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9226 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9228 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9231 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9232 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9233 contents literally. */
9236 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9238 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9242 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9244 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9248 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9250 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9254 elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9256 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tar", note);
9260 elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9262 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note);
9266 elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9268 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note);
9272 elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9274 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note);
9278 elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9280 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note);
9284 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9286 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note);
9290 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9292 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note);
9296 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9298 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note);
9302 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9304 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note);
9308 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9310 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note);
9314 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9316 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note);
9320 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9322 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note);
9326 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9328 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note);
9332 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9334 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9338 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9340 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9344 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9346 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9350 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9352 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9356 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9358 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9362 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9364 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9368 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9370 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9374 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9376 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9380 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9382 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9386 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9388 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9392 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9394 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9398 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9400 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9404 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9406 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9410 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9412 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9416 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9418 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9422 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9424 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9428 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9430 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9434 elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9436 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-sve", note);
9439 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9440 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9441 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9442 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9446 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9447 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9448 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9449 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9453 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9454 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9455 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9458 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9461 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9469 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9473 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9479 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9481 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9483 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9485 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9487 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9489 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9490 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9492 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9493 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9494 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9496 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9497 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9498 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9500 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9501 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9503 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9504 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9506 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9508 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9509 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9511 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9512 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9513 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9515 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9516 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9517 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9523 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9524 note size (ie. data object type). */
9528 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9529 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9530 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9533 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9534 int n = strlen (command);
9536 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9537 command[n - 1] = '\0';
9542 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9544 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9546 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9548 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9549 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9550 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9556 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9558 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9560 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9561 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9563 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9566 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9568 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9571 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9572 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9573 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9577 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9579 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9581 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9583 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9589 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
9590 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9591 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
9596 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
9598 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
9599 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9601 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9602 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
9604 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9606 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9607 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9608 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9611 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9613 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9617 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9618 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9619 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9620 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9623 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9624 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
9625 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
9628 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9630 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9633 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9635 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9636 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9637 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9640 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9642 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9646 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9647 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9648 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9649 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9652 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9653 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
9654 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
9657 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9659 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9661 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9664 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9671 int is_active_thread;
9674 if (note->descsz < 728)
9677 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9680 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9684 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9685 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9686 /* process_info.pid */
9687 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9688 /* process_info.signal */
9689 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9692 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9693 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9694 /* thread_info.tid */
9695 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9697 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9698 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9702 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9704 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9708 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9710 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9711 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9712 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9714 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9715 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9717 if (is_active_thread)
9718 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9722 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9723 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9724 /* module_info.base_address */
9725 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9726 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9728 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9729 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9733 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9735 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9740 sect->size = note->descsz;
9741 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9742 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9753 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9755 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9763 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9764 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9766 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9767 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9772 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9774 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9777 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9779 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9782 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9783 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9785 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9786 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9788 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9789 if (note->namesz == 6
9790 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9791 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9795 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9796 if (note->namesz == 6
9797 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9798 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9803 if (note->namesz == 6
9804 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9805 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9810 if (note->namesz == 6
9811 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9812 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9817 if (note->namesz == 6
9818 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9819 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd, note);
9824 if (note->namesz == 6
9825 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9826 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd, note);
9831 if (note->namesz == 6
9832 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9833 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd, note);
9838 if (note->namesz == 6
9839 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9840 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd, note);
9845 if (note->namesz == 6
9846 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9847 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd, note);
9851 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR:
9852 if (note->namesz == 6
9853 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9854 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, note);
9858 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR:
9859 if (note->namesz == 6
9860 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9861 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, note);
9865 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX:
9866 if (note->namesz == 6
9867 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9868 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, note);
9872 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX:
9873 if (note->namesz == 6
9874 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9875 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, note);
9880 if (note->namesz == 6
9881 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9882 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, note);
9886 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR:
9887 if (note->namesz == 6
9888 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9889 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, note);
9893 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR:
9894 if (note->namesz == 6
9895 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9896 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, note);
9900 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR:
9901 if (note->namesz == 6
9902 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9903 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, note);
9907 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9908 if (note->namesz == 6
9909 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9910 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9915 if (note->namesz == 6
9916 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9917 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9921 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9922 if (note->namesz == 6
9923 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9924 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9928 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9929 if (note->namesz == 6
9930 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9931 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9936 if (note->namesz == 6
9937 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9938 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9942 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9943 if (note->namesz == 6
9944 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9945 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9949 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9950 if (note->namesz == 6
9951 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9952 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9956 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9957 if (note->namesz == 6
9958 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9959 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9964 if (note->namesz == 6
9965 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9966 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9970 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9971 if (note->namesz == 6
9972 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9973 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9977 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9978 if (note->namesz == 6
9979 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9980 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9985 if (note->namesz == 6
9986 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9987 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
9992 if (note->namesz == 6
9993 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9994 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
9999 if (note->namesz == 6
10000 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10001 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10006 if (note->namesz == 6
10007 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10008 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
10012 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
10013 if (note->namesz == 6
10014 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10015 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
10019 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
10020 if (note->namesz == 6
10021 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10022 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
10027 if (note->namesz == 6
10028 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10029 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd, note);
10035 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
10036 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
10038 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10039 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
10046 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10051 sect->size = note->descsz;
10052 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10053 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10059 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10063 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10070 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10072 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
10074 if (note->descsz == 0)
10077 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
10078 if (build_id == NULL)
10081 build_id->size = note->descsz;
10082 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10083 abfd->build_id = build_id;
10089 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10091 switch (note->type)
10096 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
10097 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
10099 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
10100 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
10105 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10107 struct sdt_note *cur =
10108 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
10111 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
10112 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
10113 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10115 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
10121 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10123 switch (note->type)
10126 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
10134 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10138 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10141 if (note->descsz < 108)
10146 if (note->descsz < 120)
10154 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10155 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10160 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10161 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10165 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10169 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10170 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10171 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
10174 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10175 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10176 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
10179 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10182 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10183 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
10186 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10187 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10193 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10199 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10200 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10201 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10205 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10209 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10210 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10217 if (note->descsz < min_size)
10220 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10221 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10224 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10225 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10226 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10228 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10233 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10237 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10240 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10241 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10242 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10243 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10246 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10247 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10248 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10251 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10252 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10255 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10256 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10259 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10260 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10261 size, note->descpos + offset);
10265 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10267 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10269 switch (note->type)
10272 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10273 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10275 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10278 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10281 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10283 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10284 if (note->namesz == 8)
10285 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10289 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10290 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10293 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10294 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10297 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10298 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10301 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10303 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10308 sect->size = note->descsz - 4;
10309 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 4;
10310 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10315 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10316 if (note->namesz == 8)
10317 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10321 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10322 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10326 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10334 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10338 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10341 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10348 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10350 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10353 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10354 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10355 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10357 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10358 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10359 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10361 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10362 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10363 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10365 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10370 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10374 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10375 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10377 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
10379 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10380 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10381 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10382 creates a core file. */
10384 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10387 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
10388 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10389 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10392 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10396 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10398 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10399 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10401 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10402 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10403 switch (note->type)
10405 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10406 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10408 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10409 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10415 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10416 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10419 switch (note->type)
10421 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10422 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10424 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10425 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10435 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10437 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10440 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10441 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10442 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10444 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10445 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10446 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10448 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10449 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10450 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10456 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10458 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10459 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10461 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10462 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10464 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10465 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10467 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10468 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10470 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10472 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10477 sect->size = note->descsz;
10478 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10479 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10484 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10486 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10491 sect->size = note->descsz;
10492 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10493 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10502 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10504 void *ddata = note->descdata;
10511 if (note->descsz < 16)
10514 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10515 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10517 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10518 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10520 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10521 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10523 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10524 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10526 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10527 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10530 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10531 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10532 thread just in case. */
10533 if (flags & 0x00000080)
10534 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10536 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10537 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10539 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10542 strcpy (name, buf);
10544 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10548 sect->size = note->descsz;
10549 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10550 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10552 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10556 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10557 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10565 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10566 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10568 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10571 strcpy (name, buf);
10573 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10577 sect->size = note->descsz;
10578 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10579 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10581 /* This is the current thread. */
10582 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
10583 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
10588 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10589 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10590 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10591 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10594 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10596 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10597 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10599 static long tid = 1;
10601 switch (note->type)
10603 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
10604 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
10605 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
10606 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
10607 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
10608 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
10609 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
10610 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
10617 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10623 /* Use note name as section name. */
10624 len = note->namesz;
10625 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10628 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
10629 name[len - 1] = '\0';
10631 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10635 sect->size = note->descsz;
10636 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10637 sect->alignment_power = 1;
10642 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10645 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10649 size of data for note
10651 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10652 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10653 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10654 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10657 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10660 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
10668 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
10675 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
10677 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
10679 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
10682 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
10683 *bufsiz += newspace;
10684 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
10685 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
10686 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
10687 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
10691 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
10699 memcpy (dest, input, size);
10709 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
10710 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
10711 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
10712 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
10713 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
10714 be NULL terminated.
10715 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
10716 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
10717 the finer control available with later versions.
10718 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
10719 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
10720 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
10721 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
10722 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10723 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
10724 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
10727 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
10731 const char *psargs)
10733 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10735 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10738 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10739 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
10744 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10745 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10746 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10748 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10750 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10753 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10756 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10757 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10758 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10759 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10760 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10765 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10767 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10770 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10773 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10774 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10775 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10776 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10777 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10779 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
10784 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10785 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
10789 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
10790 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10791 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10793 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
10795 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
10797 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10798 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10799 &data, sizeof (data));
10803 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
10805 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10806 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10807 &data, sizeof (data));
10812 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
10813 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10814 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10816 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
10818 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
10820 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10821 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10822 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10826 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
10828 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10829 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10830 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10835 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
10842 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10844 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10847 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10849 pid, cursig, gregs);
10854 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10855 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
10856 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10858 prstatus32_t prstat;
10860 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10861 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10862 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10863 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10864 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10865 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10872 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10873 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10874 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10875 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10876 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10877 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10879 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
10885 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10887 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
10894 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10895 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10897 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
10898 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
10899 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10900 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10901 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
10902 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10903 #if !defined(gregs)
10904 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
10905 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
10907 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
10908 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
10911 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10912 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
10914 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
10916 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10918 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
10922 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10923 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10925 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10926 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10927 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10929 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10933 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10934 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10935 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10936 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10944 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10945 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10946 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10947 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10951 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
10954 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10957 const void *fpregs,
10960 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10961 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10962 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
10966 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10969 const void *xfpregs,
10972 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10973 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10974 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
10978 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10979 const void *xfpregs, int size)
10982 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
10983 note_name = "FreeBSD";
10985 note_name = "LINUX";
10986 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10987 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
10991 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
10994 const void *ppc_vmx,
10997 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10998 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10999 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
11003 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
11006 const void *ppc_vsx,
11009 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11010 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11011 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
11015 elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd,
11018 const void *ppc_tar,
11021 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11022 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11023 note_name, NT_PPC_TAR, ppc_tar, size);
11027 elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd,
11030 const void *ppc_ppr,
11033 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11034 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11035 note_name, NT_PPC_PPR, ppc_ppr, size);
11039 elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd,
11042 const void *ppc_dscr,
11045 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11046 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11047 note_name, NT_PPC_DSCR, ppc_dscr, size);
11051 elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd,
11054 const void *ppc_ebb,
11057 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11058 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11059 note_name, NT_PPC_EBB, ppc_ebb, size);
11063 elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd,
11066 const void *ppc_pmu,
11069 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11070 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11071 note_name, NT_PPC_PMU, ppc_pmu, size);
11075 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd,
11078 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr,
11081 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11082 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11083 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR, ppc_tm_cgpr, size);
11087 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd,
11090 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr,
11093 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11094 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11095 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR, ppc_tm_cfpr, size);
11099 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd,
11102 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx,
11105 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11106 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11107 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX, ppc_tm_cvmx, size);
11111 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd,
11114 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx,
11117 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11118 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11119 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX, ppc_tm_cvsx, size);
11123 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd,
11126 const void *ppc_tm_spr,
11129 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11130 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11131 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_SPR, ppc_tm_spr, size);
11135 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd,
11138 const void *ppc_tm_ctar,
11141 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11142 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11143 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR, ppc_tm_ctar, size);
11147 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd,
11150 const void *ppc_tm_cppr,
11153 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11154 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11155 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR, ppc_tm_cppr, size);
11159 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd,
11162 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr,
11165 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11166 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11167 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR, ppc_tm_cdscr, size);
11171 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
11174 const void *s390_high_gprs,
11177 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11178 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11179 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
11180 s390_high_gprs, size);
11184 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
11187 const void *s390_timer,
11190 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11191 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11192 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
11196 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
11199 const void *s390_todcmp,
11202 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11203 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11204 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
11208 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
11211 const void *s390_todpreg,
11214 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11215 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11216 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
11220 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
11223 const void *s390_ctrs,
11226 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11227 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11228 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
11232 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
11235 const void *s390_prefix,
11238 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11239 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11240 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
11244 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
11247 const void *s390_last_break,
11250 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11251 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11252 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
11253 s390_last_break, size);
11257 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
11260 const void *s390_system_call,
11263 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11264 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11265 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
11266 s390_system_call, size);
11270 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
11273 const void *s390_tdb,
11276 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11277 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11278 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
11282 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
11285 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
11288 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11289 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11290 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
11294 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
11297 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
11300 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11301 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11302 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
11303 s390_vxrs_high, size);
11307 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
11310 const void *s390_gs_cb,
11313 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11314 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11315 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
11320 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
11323 const void *s390_gs_bc,
11326 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11327 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11328 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
11333 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
11336 const void *arm_vfp,
11339 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11340 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11341 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
11345 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
11348 const void *aarch_tls,
11351 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11352 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11353 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11357 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11360 const void *aarch_hw_break,
11363 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11364 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11365 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11369 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11372 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11375 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11376 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11377 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11381 elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd,
11384 const void *aarch_sve,
11387 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11388 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11389 note_name, NT_ARM_SVE, aarch_sve, size);
11393 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
11396 const char *section,
11400 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
11401 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11402 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11403 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11404 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11405 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11406 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11407 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11408 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11409 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11410 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
11411 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11412 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
11413 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11414 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
11415 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11416 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
11417 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11418 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
11419 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11420 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
11421 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11422 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
11423 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11424 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
11425 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11426 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
11427 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11428 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
11429 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11430 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
11431 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11432 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
11433 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11434 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
11435 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11436 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11437 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11438 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11439 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11440 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11441 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11442 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
11443 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11444 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
11445 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11446 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
11447 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11448 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
11449 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11450 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
11451 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11452 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
11453 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11454 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
11455 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11456 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
11457 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11458 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
11459 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11460 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
11461 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11462 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
11463 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11464 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
11465 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11466 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
11467 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11468 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
11469 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11470 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
11471 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11476 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
11481 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
11482 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
11483 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
11484 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
11487 if (align != 4 && align != 8)
11491 while (p < buf + size)
11493 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
11494 Elf_Internal_Note in;
11496 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
11499 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
11501 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
11502 in.namedata = xnp->name;
11503 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
11506 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
11507 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
11508 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
11510 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
11511 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
11514 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
11521 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11524 const char * string;
11526 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
11530 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
11531 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
11532 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
11533 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
11534 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
11535 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
11537 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11540 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
11542 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
11543 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
11544 grokers[i].len) == 0)
11546 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
11555 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
11557 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
11560 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
11561 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
11563 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
11569 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
11576 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
11581 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
11584 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
11587 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
11591 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
11592 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
11595 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
11596 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
11606 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
11608 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
11609 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
11610 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11613 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
11615 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11617 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11621 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
11624 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
11625 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
11626 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
11627 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
11629 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
11630 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11633 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
11637 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11639 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11643 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
11644 if (num_phdrs != 0)
11645 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
11646 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
11651 enum elf_reloc_type_class
11652 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11653 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11654 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11656 return reloc_class_normal;
11659 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
11660 relocation against a local symbol. */
11663 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11664 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11666 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11668 asection *sec = *psec;
11669 bfd_vma relocation;
11671 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
11672 + sec->output_offset
11674 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
11675 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
11676 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11679 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11680 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11681 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
11684 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11685 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11686 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11687 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11688 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11689 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
11690 sec->kept_section = *psec;
11693 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
11694 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
11700 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11701 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11705 asection *sec = *psec;
11707 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11708 return sym->st_value + addend;
11710 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11711 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11712 sym->st_value + addend);
11715 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
11716 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
11717 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
11718 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
11722 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
11723 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11727 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
11729 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
11730 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11732 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
11733 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
11736 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
11738 /* Reverse the offset. */
11739 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11740 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
11742 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
11743 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
11744 offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
11750 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
11751 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
11752 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
11753 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
11754 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
11755 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
11757 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
11758 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
11759 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
11760 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
11761 the remote memory. */
11764 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
11767 bfd_size_type size,
11768 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
11769 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
11771 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
11772 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
11776 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
11777 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11778 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11783 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11786 const char *relplt_name;
11787 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
11791 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
11797 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
11800 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
11803 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
11806 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
11807 if (relplt_name == NULL)
11808 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
11809 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
11810 if (relplt == NULL)
11813 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
11814 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
11815 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
11818 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
11822 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
11823 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
11826 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
11827 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
11828 p = relplt->relocation;
11829 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11831 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
11832 if (p->addend != 0)
11835 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
11837 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
11842 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
11846 names = (char *) (s + count);
11847 p = relplt->relocation;
11849 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11854 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
11855 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
11858 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
11859 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
11860 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
11861 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
11862 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
11863 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
11865 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
11868 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
11869 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
11871 if (p->addend != 0)
11875 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
11876 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
11877 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
11878 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
11881 memcpy (names, a, len);
11884 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
11885 names += sizeof ("@plt");
11892 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
11893 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
11894 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
11895 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
11896 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
11897 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
11898 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
11899 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
11902 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
11903 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11905 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
11907 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
11909 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
11911 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
11912 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
11913 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
11914 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
11915 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
11916 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
11920 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
11921 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
11922 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
11925 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
11927 return (type == STT_FUNC
11928 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
11931 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
11932 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
11933 otherwise return zero. */
11936 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
11939 bfd_size_type size;
11941 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
11942 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
11943 || sym->section != sec)
11946 *code_off = sym->value;
11948 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
11949 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;